blob: 82a2bb2982c40ef1aec1545b3998094e5fb2ac32 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall7d384dd2009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner418f6c72008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregor314b97f2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek042411c2010-07-21 20:43:11 +000062 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlssonb633c4e2009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000381
382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattner2085fd62009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000478 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000479 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000480 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
481 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000482 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000483 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000485 << D->getIdentifier();
486 return ExprError();
487 }
488 }
489 }
490 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000491
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000492 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000493
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000494 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
495 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
496 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregor0da76df2009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000497 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000498}
499
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000500/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
501/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
502/// actual member.
503///
504/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
505/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
506/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
507/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
508/// we found.
509///
510/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
511/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
512/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
513VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
514 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000515 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
516 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
517 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
518
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000519 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000520 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
521 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
522 do {
523 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000524 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000525 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000526 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000527 else {
528 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
529 break;
530 }
531 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000532 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000533 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534
535 return BaseObject;
536}
537
538Sema::OwningExprResult
539Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
540 FieldDecl *Field,
541 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
542 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
543 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000544 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000545 AnonFields);
546
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000547 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
548 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
549 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
550 // found via name lookup.
551 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000552 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000553 if (BaseObject) {
554 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
555 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000680/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
681/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
682/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000684 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
685 return false;
686
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
688 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
689 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
690 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
691 if (!BaseRT) return false;
692
693 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000694 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000695 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
696 return false;
697 }
698
699 return true;
700}
701
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000702/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
703/// the prospective base classes.
704static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
705 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
706 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000707 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000708 return false;
709
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000710 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000711 if (!RD) return false;
712 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
713
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000714 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
715 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
716 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
717 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
718 if (!BaseRT) return false;
719
720 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000721 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
722 return false;
723 }
724
725 return true;
726}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000727
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000728enum IMAKind {
729 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
730 IMA_Static,
731
732 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
733 IMA_Mixed,
734
735 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
736 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
737 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
738
739 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
740 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
741 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
742
743 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
744 IMA_Instance,
745
746 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
747 IMA_Unresolved,
748
749 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
750 /// context is not an instance method.
751 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
752
753 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
754 /// non-class context.
755 IMA_AnonymousMember,
756
757 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
758 /// context is not an instance method.
759 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
760
761 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
762 /// class.
763 IMA_Error_Unrelated
764};
765
766/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
767/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
768/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
769/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
770/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
771/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
772static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
773 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000774 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000775
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000776 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000777 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000778 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
779 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000780
781 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
782 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
783
784 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
785 bool hasNonInstance = false;
786 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
787 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000788 NamedDecl *D = *I;
789 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000790 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
791
792 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
793 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
794 // that's a special case.
795 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
796 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
797 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
798 }
799 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
800 }
801 else
802 hasNonInstance = true;
803 }
804
805 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
806 // member reference.
807 if (Classes.empty())
808 return IMA_Static;
809
810 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
811 // an implicit member reference.
812 if (isStaticContext)
813 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
814
815 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
816 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
817 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
818 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000819 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000820 Classes))
821 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
822
823 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
824}
825
826/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
827static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
828 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
829 const LookupResult &R) {
830 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
831 SourceRange Range(Loc);
832 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
833
834 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
835 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
836 if (MD->isStatic()) {
837 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
838 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
839 << Range << R.getLookupName();
840 return;
841 }
842 }
843
844 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
845 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
846 return;
847 }
848
849 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000850}
851
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000852/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
853///
854/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000855bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
856 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000857 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
858
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000859 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000860 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000861 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
862 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000863 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000864 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000865 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
866 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000867
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000868 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
869 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
870 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
871 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000872 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000873 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
875 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
876
877 if (!R.empty()) {
878 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
879 R.suppressDiagnostics();
880
881 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
882 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
883 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
884 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
885
886 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
887 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
888 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000889 if (isInstance) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000890 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000891 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000892
893 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
894 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
895 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
896 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
897 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
898 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(R.getNameLoc(),
899 DepThisType, false);
900 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
901 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
902 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
903 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
904 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
905 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
906 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL, Name,
907 R.getNameLoc(), &TList);
908 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
909 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000910 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000911 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000912
913 // Do we really want to note all of these?
914 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
915 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
916
917 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
918 return false;
919 }
920 }
921 }
922
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000923 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000924 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000925 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000926 if (!R.empty()) {
927 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
928 if (SS.isEmpty())
929 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
930 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
931 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
932 else
933 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
934 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
935 << SS.getRange()
936 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
937 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
938 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
939 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
940 << ND->getDeclName();
941
942 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
943 return false;
944 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000945
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000946 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
947 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
948 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
949 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
950 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
951 // to recover well anyway.
952 if (SS.isEmpty())
953 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
954 else
955 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
956 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
957 << SS.getRange();
958
959 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
960 return true;
961 }
962 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000963 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000964 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000965 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000966 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000967 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000968 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000969 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
970 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000971 return true;
972 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000973 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000974 }
975
976 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
977 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
978 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
979 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
980 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
981 << SS.getRange();
982 return true;
983 }
984
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000985 // Give up, we can't recover.
986 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
987 return true;
988}
989
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +0000990static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +0000991 IdentifierInfo *II,
992 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +0000993 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
994 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
995 if (!IDecl)
996 return 0;
997 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
998 if (!ClassImpDecl)
999 return 0;
1000 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1001 if (!property)
1002 return 0;
1003 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1004 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1005 return 0;
1006 return property;
1007}
1008
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001009static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001010 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001011 IdentifierInfo *II,
1012 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1013 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001014 bool LookForIvars;
1015 if (Lookup.empty())
1016 LookForIvars = true;
1017 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1018 LookForIvars = false;
1019 else
1020 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1021 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1022 if (!LookForIvars)
1023 return 0;
1024
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001025 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1026 if (!IDecl)
1027 return 0;
1028 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001029 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1030 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001031 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1032 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1033 if (!property)
1034 return 0;
1035 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1036 DynamicImplSeen =
1037 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1038 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001039 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1040 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001041 NameLoc,
1042 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1043 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1044 (Expr *)0, true);
1045 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1046 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1047 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1048 return Ivar;
1049 }
1050 return 0;
1051}
1052
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001053Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001054 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001055 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1056 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1057 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1058 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1059 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1060
1061 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001062 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001063
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001064 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001065
1066 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1067 DeclarationName Name;
1068 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1069 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001070 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1071 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001072
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001073 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001074
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001075 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1076 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001077 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1078 // (note: handled after lookup)
1079 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1080 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1081 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1083 // names a dependent type.
1084 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1085 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001086 bool DependentID = false;
1087 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1088 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1089 DependentID = true;
1090 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1091 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1092 if (DC) {
1093 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1094 return ExprError();
1095 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1096 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1097 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1098 } else {
1099 DependentID = true;
1100 }
1101 }
1102
1103 if (DependentID) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001104 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001105 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001106 TemplateArgs);
1107 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001108 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001109 // Perform the required lookup.
1110 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1111 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001112 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1113 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1114 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1115 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1116 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001117 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1118 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1119 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001120 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001121 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001122 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001123
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001124 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1125 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001126 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1127 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001128 if (E.isInvalid())
1129 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001130
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001131 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1132 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001133 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1134 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001135 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001136 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1137 isAddressOfOperand);
1138 }
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001139 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001140 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001141
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001142 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1143 return ExprError();
1144
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001145 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1146 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001147 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001148
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001149 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001150 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1152 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1153 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1154 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1155 }
1156
1157 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1158 // call, diagnose the problem.
1159 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001160 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001161 return ExprError();
1162
1163 assert(!R.empty() &&
1164 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001165
1166 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1167 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001168 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001169 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1170 R.clear();
1171 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1172 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1173 return move(E);
1174 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001175 }
1176 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001177
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001178 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1179 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1180
1181 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001182 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001183 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1184 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001185 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1186 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1187 if (Property) {
1188 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1189 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
1190 }
1191 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001192 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001193 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1194 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1195 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1196 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1197 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1198 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001199 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001200 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001201
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001202 QualType T = Func->getType();
1203 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001204 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001205 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1206 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001207 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001208 }
1209 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001210
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001211 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1212 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1213 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1214 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1215 // class member access expression.
1216 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1217 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001218 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001219 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001220 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1221 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001222 }
1223
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001224 if (TemplateArgs)
1225 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001226
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001227 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1228}
1229
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001230/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1231Sema::OwningExprResult
1232Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1233 LookupResult &R,
1234 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1235 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1236 case IMA_Instance:
1237 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1238
1239 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1240 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1241 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1242 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1243
1244 case IMA_Mixed:
1245 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1246 case IMA_Unresolved:
1247 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1248
1249 case IMA_Static:
1250 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1251 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1252 if (TemplateArgs)
1253 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1254 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1255
1256 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1257 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1258 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1259 return ExprError();
1260 }
1261
1262 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1263 return ExprError();
1264}
1265
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001266/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1267/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1268/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1269/// this path.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001270Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001271Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001272 DeclarationName Name,
1273 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1274 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001275 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001276 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1277
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001278 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001279 return ExprError();
1280
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001281 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1282 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1283
1284 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1285 return ExprError();
1286
1287 if (R.empty()) {
1288 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1289 return ExprError();
1290 }
1291
1292 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1293}
1294
1295/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1296/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1297/// additional lookup.
1298///
1299/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1300/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1301///
1302/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1303Sema::OwningExprResult
1304Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001305 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001306 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001307 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001308
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001309 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1310 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1311 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1312 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1313 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1314
1315 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1316 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1317 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001318 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001319
1320 bool LookForIvars;
1321 if (Lookup.empty())
1322 LookForIvars = true;
1323 else if (IsClassMethod)
1324 LookForIvars = false;
1325 else
1326 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1327 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001328 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001329 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001330 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001331 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1332 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1333 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1334 if (IsClassMethod)
1335 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1336 << IV->getDeclName());
1337
1338 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1339 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1340 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1341 return ExprError();
1342
1343 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1344 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1345 return ExprError();
1346
1347 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1348 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1349 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1350 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1351
1352 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1353 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1354 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1355 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001356 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001357 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1358 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1359 SelfName, false, false);
1360 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1361 return Owned(new (Context)
1362 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1363 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1364 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001365 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001366 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001367 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001368 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1369 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1370 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1371 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1372 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1373 }
1374 }
1375
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001376 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1377 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1378 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1379 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1380 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1381 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1382 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1383 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1384 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1385 }
1386 }
1387 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001388 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1389 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001390}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001391
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001392/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1393///
1394/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1395///
1396/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1397/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1398/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1399/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1400///
1401/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1402/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1403/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1404/// the class declaring the member.
1405///
1406/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1407/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1408/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001409bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001410Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1411 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001412 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001413 NamedDecl *Member) {
1414 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1415 if (!RD)
1416 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001417
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001418 QualType DestRecordType;
1419 QualType DestType;
1420 QualType FromRecordType;
1421 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1422 bool PointerConversions = false;
1423 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1424 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001425
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001426 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1427 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1428 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1429 PointerConversions = true;
1430 } else {
1431 DestType = DestRecordType;
1432 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001433 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001434 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1435 if (Method->isStatic())
1436 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001437
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001438 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1439 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001440
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001441 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1442 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1443 PointerConversions = true;
1444 } else {
1445 FromRecordType = FromType;
1446 DestType = DestRecordType;
1447 }
1448 } else {
1449 // No conversion necessary.
1450 return false;
1451 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001452
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001453 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1454 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001455
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001456 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1457 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1458 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001459
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001460 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1461 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1462
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001463 ImplicitCastExpr::ResultCategory Category = CastCategory(From);
1464
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001465 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001466 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001467 // class name.
1468 //
1469 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1470 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1471 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1472 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1473 //
1474 // class Base { public: int x; };
1475 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1476 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1477 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1478 //
1479 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1480 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1481 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1482 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001483 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001484 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1485 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1486 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1487
1488 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1489
1490 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1491 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1492 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1493 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001494 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001495 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001496 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001497 return true;
1498
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001499 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001500 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001501 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001502 Category, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001503
1504 FromType = QType;
1505 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1506
1507 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1508 // we're done.
1509 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1510 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001511 }
1512 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001513
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001514 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001515
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001516 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1517 // down to the using declaration's type.
1518 //
1519 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1520 // class ever has member declarations.
1521 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1522 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1523 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1524 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1525
1526 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1527 // conversion is non-trivial.
1528 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1529 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001530 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001531 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001532 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001533 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001534
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001535 QualType UType = URecordType;
1536 if (PointerConversions)
1537 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001538 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001539 Category, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001540 FromType = UType;
1541 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1542 }
1543
1544 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1545 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1546 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001547 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001548
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001549 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1550 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1551 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001552 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001553 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001554
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001555 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001556 Category, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001557 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001558}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001559
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001560/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001561static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001562 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001563 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1564 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001565 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1566 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1567 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001568 if (SS.isSet()) {
1569 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1570 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001571 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001572
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001573 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001574 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001575}
1576
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001577/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1578/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1579/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1580/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001581Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001582Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1583 LookupResult &R,
1584 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1585 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001586 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1587
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001588 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001589
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001590 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1591 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001592 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001593 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001594 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001595 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001596 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001597
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001598 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1599 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001600 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1601 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001602 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1603 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001604 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1605 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1606 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1607 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001608 }
1609
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001610 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1611 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1612 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001613 SS,
1614 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1615 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001616}
1617
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001618bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001619 const LookupResult &R,
1620 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001621 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1622 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1623 return false;
1624
1625 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001626 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001627 return false;
1628
1629 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001630 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001631 return false;
1632
1633 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1634 // normal lookup:
1635 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1636 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1637
1638 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1639 // -- a declaration of a class member
1640 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1641 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001642 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001643 return false;
1644
1645 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1646 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1647 // using-declaration
1648 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1649 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1650 // turn off ADL anyway).
1651 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1652 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1653 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1654 return false;
1655
1656 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1657 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1658 // template
1659 // And also for builtin functions.
1660 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1661 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1662
1663 // But also builtin functions.
1664 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1665 return false;
1666 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1667 return false;
1668 }
1669
1670 return true;
1671}
1672
1673
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001674/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1675/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1676/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1677/// will in fact be used.
1678static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1679 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1680 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1681 return true;
1682 }
1683
1684 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1685 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1686 return true;
1687 }
1688
1689 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1690 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1691 return true;
1692 }
1693
1694 return false;
1695}
1696
1697Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001698Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001699 LookupResult &R,
1700 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001701 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1702 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001703 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001704 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001705
1706 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1707 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1708 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001709 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1710 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001711 return ExprError();
1712
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001713 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1714 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1715 // we've picked a target.
1716 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1717
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001718 bool Dependent
1719 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001720 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001721 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001722 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1723 SS.getRange(),
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001724 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001725 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1726 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001727
1728 return Owned(ULE);
1729}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001730
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001731
1732/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1733Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001734Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001735 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1736 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001737 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1738 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001739
1740 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1741 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001742
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001743 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1744 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1745 // a template argument list.
1746 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1747 << Template << SS.getRange();
1748 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1749 return ExprError();
1750 }
1751
1752 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1753 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1754 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001755 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001756 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001757 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001758 return ExprError();
1759 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001760
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001761 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1762 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1763 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1764 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001765 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001766 return ExprError();
1767
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001768 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1769 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001770 return ExprError();
1771
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001772 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1773 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1774 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1775 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001776 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001777 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1778 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1779 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001780 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001781 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001782 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1783 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1784 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1785 return ExprError();
1786 }
1787
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001788 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001789 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1790 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1791 return ExprError();
1792 }
1793
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001794 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001795 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001796 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001797 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001798 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001799 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1800 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001801 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001802
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001803 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001804 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001805 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1806 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001807 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001808 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1809 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1810 Expr *E = new (Context)
1811 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1812 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001813
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001814 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
1815 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001816 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001817 SourceLocation(),
1818 Owned(E));
1819 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
1820 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
1821 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1822 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1823 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001824 }
1825 }
1826 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001827 }
1828 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1829 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001830
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001831 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001832}
1833
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001834Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1835 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001836 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001837
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001838 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001839 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001840 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1841 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1842 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001843 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001844
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001845 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1846 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001847
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001848 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001849 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1850 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001851 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001852 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001853 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001854 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001855
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001856 QualType ResTy;
1857 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1858 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1859 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001860 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001861
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001862 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001863 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001864 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1865 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001866 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001867}
1868
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001869Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001870 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001871 bool Invalid = false;
1872 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1873 if (Invalid)
1874 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001875
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001876 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1877 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001878 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001879 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001880
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001881 QualType Ty;
1882 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1883 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1884 else if (Literal.isWide())
1885 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001886 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1887 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001888 else
1889 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001890
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001891 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1892 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001893 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001894}
1895
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001896Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1897 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001898 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1899 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001900 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001901 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001902 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001903 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001904 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001905
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001906 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001907 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1908 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001909 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001910
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001911 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001912 bool Invalid = false;
1913 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1914 if (Invalid)
1915 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001917 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001918 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1919 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001920 return ExprError();
1921
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001922 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001923
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001924 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001925 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001926 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001927 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001928 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001929 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001930 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001931 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001932
1933 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1934
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001935 using llvm::APFloat;
1936 APFloat Val(Format);
1937
1938 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001939
1940 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1941 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1942 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1943 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001944 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001945 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001946 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001947 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001948 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1949 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001950 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001951 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1952 }
1953
1954 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1955 << Ty
1956 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1957 }
1958
1959 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattner001d64d2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001960 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001961
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001962 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001963 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001964 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001965 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001966
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001967 // long long is a C99 feature.
1968 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001969 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001970 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1971
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001972 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001973 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001974
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001975 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1976 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1977 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001978 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1979 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001980 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001981 } else {
1982 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1983 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001984
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001985 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1986 // be an unsigned int.
1987 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1988
1989 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001990 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001991 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1992 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001993 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001994
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001995 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1996 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1997 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1998 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001999 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002000 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002001 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002002 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002003 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002004 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002005
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002006 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002007 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002008 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002009
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002010 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2011 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2012 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2013 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002014 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002015 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002016 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002017 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002018 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002019 }
2020
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002021 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002022 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002023 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002024
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002025 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2026 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2027 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2028 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002029 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002030 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002031 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002032 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002033 }
2034 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002035
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002036 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2037 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002038 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002039 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002040 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002041 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002042 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002043
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002044 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2045 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002046 }
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002047 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002048 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002049
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002050 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2051 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002052 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002053 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002054
2055 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002056}
2057
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002058Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2059 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002060 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002061 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002062 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002063}
2064
2065/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2066/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002067bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002068 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2069 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2070 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002071 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2072 return false;
2073
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002074 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2075 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2076 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2077 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2078 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2079 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2080
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002081 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002082 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002083 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002084 if (isSizeof)
2085 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2086 return false;
2087 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002088
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002089 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002090 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002091 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2092 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002093 return false;
2094 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002095
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002096 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002097 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2098 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002099 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002100
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002101 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002102 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002103 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002104 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2105 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002106 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002107
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002108 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2109 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2110 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2111 return true;
2112 }
2113
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002114 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002115}
2116
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002117bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2118 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2119 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002120
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002121 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002122 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2123 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002124
2125 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2126 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2127 return false;
2128
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002129 if (E->getBitField()) {
2130 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2131 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002132 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002133
2134 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2135 // bit-field.
2136 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002137 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002138 return false;
2139
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002140 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2141}
2142
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002143/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002144Action::OwningExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002145Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002146 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002147 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002148 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002149 return ExprError();
2150
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002151 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002152
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002153 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2154 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2155 return ExprError();
2156
2157 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002158 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002159 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2160 R.getEnd()));
2161}
2162
2163/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2164/// operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002165Action::OwningExprResult
2166Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002167 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2168 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2169 bool isInvalid = false;
2170 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2171 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2172 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2173 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002174 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002175 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2176 isInvalid = true;
2177 } else {
2178 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2179 }
2180
2181 if (isInvalid)
2182 return ExprError();
2183
2184 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2185 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2186 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2187 R.getEnd()));
2188}
2189
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002190/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2191/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2192/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002193Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002194Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2195 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002196 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002197 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002198
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002199 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002200 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2201 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2202 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002203 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002204
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002205 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2206 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2207 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2208
2209 if (Result.isInvalid())
2210 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2211
2212 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002213}
2214
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002215QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002216 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2217 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002218
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002219 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002220 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002221 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002222
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002223 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2224 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2225 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002226
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002227 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002228 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2229 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002230 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002231}
2232
2233
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002234
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002235Action::OwningExprResult
2236Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2237 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002238 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2239 switch (Kind) {
2240 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2241 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2242 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2243 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002244
Eli Friedmane4216e92009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002245 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002246}
2247
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002248Action::OwningExprResult
2249Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2250 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002251 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2252 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2253
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002254 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2255 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002256
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002257 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002258 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2259 Base.release();
2260 Idx.release();
2261 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2262 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2263 }
2264
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002265 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002266 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002267 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2268 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2269 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002270 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002271 }
2272
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002273 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2274}
2275
2276
2277Action::OwningExprResult
2278Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2279 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2280 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2281 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2282
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002283 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002284 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2285 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2286 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002287
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002288 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002289
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002290 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002291 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002292 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002293 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002294 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2295 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002296 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2297 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2298 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2299 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002300 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002301 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2302 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002303 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002304 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002305 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002306 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2307 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002308 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002309 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002310 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002311 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2312 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2313 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002314 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002315 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002316 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2317 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2318 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2319 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002320 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002321 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002322 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002323
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002324 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2325 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002326 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2327 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002328 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002329 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2330 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2331 // force the promotion here.
2332 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2333 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002334 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2335 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002336 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2337
2338 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2339 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002340 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002341 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2342 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2343 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2344 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002345 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2346 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002347 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2348
2349 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2350 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002351 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002352 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002353 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2354 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002355 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002356 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002357 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002358 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2359 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002360
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002361 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002362 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2363 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002364 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2365
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002366 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002367 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2368 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002369 // incomplete types are not object types.
2370 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2371 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2372 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2373 return ExprError();
2374 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002375
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002376 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002377 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002378 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2379 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002380 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002381
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002382 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002383 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002384 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2385 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2386 return ExprError();
2387 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002388
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002389 Base.release();
2390 Idx.release();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002391 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002392 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002393}
2394
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002395QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002396CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002397 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002398 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002399 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2400 // see FIXME there.
2401 //
2402 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2403 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002404 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002405
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002406 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002407 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002408
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002409 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002410 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2411 // to be selected.
2412 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002413
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002414 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2415 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002416 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002417
2418 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2419 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002420 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002421 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2422 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002423 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002424 do
2425 compStr++;
2426 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002427 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002428 do
2429 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002430 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002431 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002432
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002433 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002434 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2435 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002436 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2437 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002438 return QualType();
2439 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002440
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002441 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2442 // operates on.
2443 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002444 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002445
2446 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002447 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002448
2449 while (*compStr) {
2450 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2451 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2452 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2453 return QualType();
2454 }
2455 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002456 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002457
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002458 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002459 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002460 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002461 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002462 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002463 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002464 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002465 if (HexSwizzle)
2466 CompSize--;
2467
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002468 if (CompSize == 1)
2469 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002470
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002471 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002472 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002473 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2474 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2475 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2476 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002477 }
2478 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002479}
2480
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002481static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002482 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002483 const Selector &Sel,
2484 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002485
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002486 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002487 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002488 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002489 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002490
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002491 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2492 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002493 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002494 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002495 return D;
2496 }
2497 return 0;
2498}
2499
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002500static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002501 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002502 const Selector &Sel,
2503 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002504 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2505 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002506 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002507 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002508 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002509 GDecl = PD;
2510 break;
2511 }
2512 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002513 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002514 GDecl = OMD;
2515 break;
2516 }
2517 }
2518 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002519 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002520 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2521 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002522 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002523 if (GDecl)
2524 return GDecl;
2525 }
2526 }
2527 return GDecl;
2528}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002529
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002530Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002531Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2532 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002533 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2534 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2535 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2536 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2537 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2538
2539 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2540 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2541 //
2542 // T* t;
2543 // t.f;
2544 //
2545 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2546 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2547 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2548 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002549 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002550 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2551 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002552 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002553 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002554 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002555 return ExprError();
2556 }
2557 }
2558
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002559 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002560 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002561
2562 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2563 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002564 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002565 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2566 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2567 SS.getRange(),
2568 FirstQualifierInScope,
2569 Name, NameLoc,
2570 TemplateArgs));
2571}
2572
2573/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2574/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2575/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2576static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2577 Expr *BaseExpr,
2578 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002579 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002580 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002581 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2582 // diagnostics.
2583 if (!BaseExpr)
2584 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002585
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002586 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2587 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002588}
2589
2590// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2591// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2592// type. The restriction here is:
2593//
2594// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2595// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2596// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2597//
2598// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2599// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2600// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2601// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2602bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2603 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002604 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002605 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002606 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2607 if (!BaseRT) {
2608 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2609 // dependent.
2610 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2611 return false;
2612 }
2613 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002614
2615 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002616 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2617 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002618 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002619 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002620
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002621 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002622 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2623 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2624 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002625
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002626 if (!DC->isRecord())
2627 continue;
2628
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002629 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002630 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002631
2632 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2633 return false;
2634 }
2635
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002636 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002637 return true;
2638}
2639
2640static bool
2641LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2642 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002643 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2644 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002645 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2646 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002647 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002648 << BaseRange))
2649 return true;
2650
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002651 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2652 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2653 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2654
2655 bool MOUS;
2656 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2657 return false;
2658 }
2659
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002660 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2661 if (SS.isSet()) {
2662 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2663 // nested-name-specifier.
2664 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2665
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002666 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002667 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2668 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2669 return true;
2670 }
2671
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002672 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002673
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002674 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2675 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2676 << DC << SS.getRange();
2677 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002678 }
2679 }
2680
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002681 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2682 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002683
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002684 if (!R.empty())
2685 return false;
2686
2687 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2688 // for typos.
2689 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002690 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002691 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002692 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2693 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2694 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002695 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2696 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002697 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2698 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2699 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002700 return false;
2701 } else {
2702 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002703 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002704 }
2705
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002706 return false;
2707}
2708
2709Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002710Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002711 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002712 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002713 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2714 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2715 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2716 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2717
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002718 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2719 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002720 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002721 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2722 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2723 Name, NameLoc,
2724 TemplateArgs);
2725
2726 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002727
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002728 // Implicit member accesses.
2729 if (!Base) {
2730 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2731 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2732 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2733 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002734 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002735 return ExprError();
2736
2737 // Explicit member accesses.
2738 } else {
2739 OwningExprResult Result =
2740 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002741 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002742
2743 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2744 Owned(Base);
2745 return ExprError();
2746 }
2747
2748 if (Result.get())
2749 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002750
2751 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2752 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002753 }
2754
Sebastian Redl0aa866f2010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002755 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002756 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2757 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002758}
2759
2760Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002761Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2762 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2763 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002764 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002766 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2767 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002768 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002769 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002770 if (IsArrow) {
2771 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2772 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2773 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002774 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002775
2776 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2777 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2778 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2779 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2780
2781 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002782 return ExprError();
2783
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002784 if (R.empty()) {
2785 // Rederive where we looked up.
2786 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2787 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2788 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002789
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002790 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002791 << MemberName << DC
2792 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002793 return ExprError();
2794 }
2795
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002796 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2797 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2798 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2799 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2800 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2801 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2802 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2803 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2804 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2805 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002806 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002807 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002808 return ExprError();
2809
2810 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2811 // result.
2812 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002813 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002814 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002815 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002816 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002817
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002818 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2819 // pick a member.
2820 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2821
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002822 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2823 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2824 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002825 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2826 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002827 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2828 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002829 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002830
2831 return Owned(MemExpr);
2832 }
2833
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002834 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002835 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2837
2838 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2839
2840 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2841 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2842 // error cases.
2843 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2844 return ExprError();
2845
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002846 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2847 if (!BaseExpr) {
2848 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002849 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002850 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2851
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002852 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2853 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2854 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2855 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002856 }
2857
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002858 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2859 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2860 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2861 // explicitly qualified.
2862 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2863 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2864 }
2865
2866 // Check the use of this member.
2867 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2868 Owned(BaseExpr);
2869 return ExprError();
2870 }
2871
2872 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2873 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2874 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002875 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2876 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002877 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2878 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2879
2880 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2881 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2882 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2883 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2884 else {
2885 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2886 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2887 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2888
2889 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2890 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2891
2892 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2893 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2894 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2895 }
2896
2897 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002898 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002899 return ExprError();
2900 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002901 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002902 }
2903
2904 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2905 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2906 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002907 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002908 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2909 }
2910
2911 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2912 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2913 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002914 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002915 MemberFn->getType()));
2916 }
2917
2918 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2919 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2920 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002921 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002922 }
2923
2924 Owned(BaseExpr);
2925
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002926 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002927 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002928 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2929 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2930 else
2931 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2932 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002933
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002934 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2935 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002936 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002937 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002938}
2939
2940/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2941/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2942/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2943/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2944/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2945/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2946/// an ordinary member expression.
2947///
2948/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2949/// fixed for ObjC++.
2950Sema::OwningExprResult
2951Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002952 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002953 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002954 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002955 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002956
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002957 // Perform default conversions.
2958 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002959
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002960 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002961 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2962
2963 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2964 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002965
2966 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002967 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002968 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2969 // call, and continue on.
2970 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2971 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2972 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2973 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2974 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002975 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2976 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002977 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2978 ->isRecordType()))) {
2979 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2980 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2981 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002982 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002983
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002984 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002985 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002986 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00002987 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002988 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002989 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002990
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002991 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2992 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2993 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2994 }
2995 }
2996 }
2997
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002998 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2999 // use that.
3000 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003001 if (IsArrow) {
3002 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3003 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3004 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003005 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003006 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003007 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3008 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003009 }
3010 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003011 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3012 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3013 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3014 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003015 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003016 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003017 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003018
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003019 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3020 // use that.
3021 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3022 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3023 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3024 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3025 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
3026 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
3027 }
3028 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003029
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003030 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003031
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003032 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003033 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003034 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3035 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3036 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3037 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3038 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3039 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3040 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3041 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3042 // Check the use of this method.
3043 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3044 return ExprError();
3045 }
3046 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3047 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3048 Selector SetterSel =
3049 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3050 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3051 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3052 if (!Setter) {
3053 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3054 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003055 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003056 }
3057 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3058 if (!Setter)
3059 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003060
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003061 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3062 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003063
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003064 if (Getter || Setter) {
3065 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003066
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003067 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003068 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003069 else
3070 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3071 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3072 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003073 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003074 PType,
3075 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3076 }
3077 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3078 << MemberName << BaseType);
3079 }
3080 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003081
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003082 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3083 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3084 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003085 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003086 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003087
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003088 if (IsArrow) {
3089 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003090 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003091 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3092 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003093 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3094 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3095 // struct MyRecord foo;
3096 // foo->bar
3097 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3098 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3099 // by now.
3100 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3101 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003102 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003103 IsArrow = false;
3104 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003105 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3106 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3107 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003108 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003109 } else {
3110 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3111 // type *foo;
3112 // foo.bar
3113 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3114 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3115 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3116 // the appropriate pointer type
3117 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3118 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3119 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3120 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3121 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003122 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003123 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3124 IsArrow = true;
3125 }
3126 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003127 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003128
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003129 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003130 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003131 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003132 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003133 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003134 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003135 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003136
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003137 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3138 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003139 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003140 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003141 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003142 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3143 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3144 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3145 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003146 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3147
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003148 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003149 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003150
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003151 if (!IV) {
3152 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3153 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3154 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003155 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003156 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003157 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003158 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3159 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003160 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3161 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003162 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003163 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003164 } else {
3165 Res.clear();
3166 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003167 }
3168 }
3169
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003170 if (IV) {
3171 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3172 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3173 // error cases.
3174 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3175 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003176
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003177 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3178 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3179 return ExprError();
3180 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3181 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3182 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3183 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3184 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3185 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3186 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3187 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3188 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3189 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3190 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3191 // AST for a function decl.
3192 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003193 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003194 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3195 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3196 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3197 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3198 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3199 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003200
3201 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3202 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003203 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003204 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003205 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003206 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3207 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003208 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003209 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003210 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003211
3212 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3213 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003214 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003215 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003216 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003217 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003218 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003219 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003220 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003221 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003222 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3223 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003224 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003225 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003226
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003227 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003228 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003229 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3230 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3231 // Check the use of this declaration
3232 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3233 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003234
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003235 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3236 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3237 }
3238 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3239 // Check the use of this method.
3240 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3241 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003242
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003243 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003244 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor04badcf2010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003245 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3246 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003247 }
3248 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003249
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003250 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003251 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003252 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003253
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003254 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3255 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003256 if (!IsArrow)
3257 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3258 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003259 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003260
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003261 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003262 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003263 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3264 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003265 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003266 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003267 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003268
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003269 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003270 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003271 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003272 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3273 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003274 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003275 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003276 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003277 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003278
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003279 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3280 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3281
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003282 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003283}
3284
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003285/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3286/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3287/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3288/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3289/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3290///
3291/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3292/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3293/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3294/// only be called
3295/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3296/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3297/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3298Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3299 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3300 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003301 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003302 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3303 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3304 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3305 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3306 return ExprError();
3307
3308 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3309
3310 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3311 DeclarationName Name;
3312 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3313 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3314 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3315 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3316
3317 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3318
3319 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3320 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3321 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3322
3323 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3324 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3325
3326 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3327 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003328 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3329 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003330 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003331 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3332 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3333 Name, NameLoc,
3334 TemplateArgs);
3335 } else {
3336 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003337 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3338 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003339
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003340 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3341 Owned(Base);
3342 return ExprError();
3343 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003344
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003345 if (Result.get()) {
3346 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3347 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3348 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3349 // call now.
3350 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3351 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
3352 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003353
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003354 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003355 }
3356
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003357 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003358 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3359 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003360 }
3361
3362 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003363}
3364
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003365Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3366 FunctionDecl *FD,
3367 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3368 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3369 Diag (CallLoc,
3370 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3371 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003372 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003373 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3374 } else {
3375 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3376 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3377
3378 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor525f96c2010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003379 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3380 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003381
Douglas Gregor24bae922010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003382 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3383 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3384 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3385 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003386
John McCallce3ff2b2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003387 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003388 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003389 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003390
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003391 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3392 InitializedEntity Entity
3393 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3394 InitializationKind Kind
3395 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3396 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3397 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3398
3399 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003400 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003401 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3402 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003403 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003404
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003405 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003406 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003407 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003408 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003409
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003410 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3411 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3412 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003413 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3414 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson337cba42009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003415 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3416 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003417 }
3418
3419 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003420 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003421}
3422
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003423/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3424/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3425/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3426/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3427/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3428/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003429bool
3430Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003431 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003432 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003433 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3434 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003435 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003436 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3437 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003438 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003439
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003440 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3441 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3442 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3443 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3444 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003445 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003446 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003447 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003448 }
3449
3450 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3451 // them.
3452 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3453 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3454 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3455 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003456 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003457 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003458 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3459 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3460 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003461 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003462 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003463 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003464 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003465 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003466 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003467 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3468 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3469 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3470 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3471 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003472 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003473 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003474 if (Invalid)
3475 return true;
3476 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3477 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3478 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003479
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003480 return false;
3481}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003482
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003483bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3484 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3485 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3486 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3487 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3488 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003489 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003490 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3491 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3492 bool Invalid = false;
3493 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3494 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3495 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3496 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003497 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003498 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003499 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003500
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003501 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003502 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3503 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003504
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003505 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3506 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003507 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003508 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003509 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003510
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003511 // Pass the argument
3512 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3513 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3514 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003515
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003516
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003517 InitializedEntity Entity =
3518 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3519 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3520 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3521 SourceLocation(),
3522 Owned(Arg));
3523 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3524 return true;
3525
3526 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003527 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003528 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003529
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003530 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003531 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003532 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3533 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003534
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003535 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003536 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003537 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003538 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003539
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003540 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003541 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003542 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003543 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003544 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003545 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003546 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003547 }
3548 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003549 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003550}
3551
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003552/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003553/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3554/// locations.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003555Action::OwningExprResult
3556Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3557 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003558 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003559 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003560
3561 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3562 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003563
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003564 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003565 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner74c469f2007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003566 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003567
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003568 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003569 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3570 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3571 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3572 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3573 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003574 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003575 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3576 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003577
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003578 NumArgs = 0;
3579 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003580
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003581 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3582 RParenLoc));
3583 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003584
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003585 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003586 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003587 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3588 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003589 bool Dependent = false;
3590 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3591 Dependent = true;
3592 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3593 Dependent = true;
3594
3595 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003596 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003597 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3598
3599 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3600 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3601 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3602 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3603
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003604 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3605
3606 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3607 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3608 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3609 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3610 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3611 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3612 // method template.
3613 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003614 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3615 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003616 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003617
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003618 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3619 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003620 }
3621
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003622 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003623 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003624 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003625 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003626 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3627 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003628 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003629
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003630 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003631 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003632 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3633 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003634 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3635 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003636 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003637
3638 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3639 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003640 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3641 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003642
3643 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3644 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003645 TheCall.get(), 0))
3646 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003647
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003648 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003649 RParenLoc))
3650 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003651
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003652 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3653 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003654 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003655 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3656 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003657 }
3658 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003659 }
3660
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003661 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003662 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003663 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003664
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003665 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003666 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3667 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003668 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003669 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003670 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003671
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003672 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3673 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3674 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3675
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003676 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3677}
3678
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003679/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3680/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003681/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3682/// block-pointer type.
3683///
3684/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3685Sema::OwningExprResult
3686Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3687 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3688 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3689 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3690 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3691
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003692 // Promote the function operand.
3693 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3694
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003695 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3696 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003697 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3698 Args, NumArgs,
3699 Context.BoolTy,
3700 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003701
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003702 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3703 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3704 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3705 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003706 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003707 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003708 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3709 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003710 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003711 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003712 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003713 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003714 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003715 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003716 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3717 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3718
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003719 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003720 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003721 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3722 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003723 return ExprError();
3724
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003725 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003726 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003727
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003728 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003729 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003730 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003731 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003732 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003733 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003734
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003735 if (FDecl) {
3736 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3737 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3738 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003739 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003740 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003741 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003742 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3743 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3744 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3745 }
3746 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003747 }
3748
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003749 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003750 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3751 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3752 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003753 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3754 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003755 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3756 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003757 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003758 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003759 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003760 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003761
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003762 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3763 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003764 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3765 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003766
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003767 // Check for sentinels
3768 if (NDecl)
3769 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003770
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003771 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003772 if (FDecl) {
3773 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3774 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003775
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003776 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003777 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3778 } else if (NDecl) {
3779 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3780 return ExprError();
3781 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003782
Anders Carlssonec74c592009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003783 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003784}
3785
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003786Action::OwningExprResult
3787Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3788 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003789 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003790 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003791 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003792
3793 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3794 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3795 if (!TInfo)
3796 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3797
3798 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3799}
3800
3801Action::OwningExprResult
3802Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3803 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3804 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003805 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003806
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003807 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003808 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003809 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3810 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003811 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3812 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003813 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003814 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003815 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003816 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003817
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003818 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003819 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003820 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003821 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003822 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003823 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3824 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3825 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3826 &literalType);
3827 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003828 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003829 InitExpr.release();
3830 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003831
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003832 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003833 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003834 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003835 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003836 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003837
3838 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003839
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003840 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003841 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003842}
3843
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003844Action::OwningExprResult
3845Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003846 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3847 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3848 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003849
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003850 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003851 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003852
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003853 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3854 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003855 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003856 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003857}
3858
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003859static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3860 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003861 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003862 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3863
3864 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3865 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003866 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3867 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahaniana7fa7cd2009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003868 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003869 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3870 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3871 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003872
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003873 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3874 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3875 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3876 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3877 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3878 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3879 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3880 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003881
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003882 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3883 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3884 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3885 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3886 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3887 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003888
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003889 // FIXME: Assert here.
3890 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3891 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3892}
3893
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003894/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003895bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003896 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003897 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003898 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003899 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003900 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3901 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003902
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003903 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003904
3905 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3906 // type needs to be scalar.
3907 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3908 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003909 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3910 return false;
3911 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003912
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003913 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3914 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3915 return true;
3916
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003917 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003918 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003919 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3920 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003921 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003922 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3923 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003924 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003925 return false;
3926 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003927
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003928 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003929 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003930 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003931 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003932 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003933 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003934 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003935 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003936 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3937 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3938 break;
3939 }
3940 }
3941 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3942 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3943 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003944 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003945 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003946 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003947
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003948 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3949 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3950 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3951 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003952
3953 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003954 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003955 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3956 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003957 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003958 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003959
3960 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003961 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003962
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003963 if (castType->isVectorType())
3964 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3965 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3966 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3967
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003968 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3969 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003970
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003971 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003972 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003973 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003974 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003975 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3976 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3977 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3978 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003979 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003980 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3981 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3982 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003983 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003984
3985 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003986 return false;
3987}
3988
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003989bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3990 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003991 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003992
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003993 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003994 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003995 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003996 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003997 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003998 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003999 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004000 } else
4001 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004002 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004003 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004004
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004005 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004006 return false;
4007}
4008
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004009bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004010 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004011 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004012
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004013 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004014
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004015 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4016 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004017 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4018 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4019 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4020 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004021 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004022 return false;
4023 }
4024
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004025 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004026 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4027 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004028 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4029 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4030 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4031 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004032
4033 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4034 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4035 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004036
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004037 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004038 return false;
4039}
4040
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004041Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004042Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004043 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4044 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
4045 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004046
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004047 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4048 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4049 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004050 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004051
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004052 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004053 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004054 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004055 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
4056 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004057
4058 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4059}
4060
4061Action::OwningExprResult
4062Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4063 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4064 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4065
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004066 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004067 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004068 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004069 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004070 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004071
Douglas Gregord6e44a32010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004072 Op.release();
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004073 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(
4074 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004075 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssoncdb61972009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004076 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004077}
4078
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004079/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4080/// of comma binary operators.
4081Action::OwningExprResult
4082Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4083 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4084 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4085 if (!E)
4086 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004087
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004088 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004089
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004090 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4091 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4092 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004093
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004094 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4095}
4096
4097Action::OwningExprResult
4098Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4099 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004100 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004101 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004102 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004103 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004104
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004105 // Check for an altivec literal,
4106 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004107 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4108 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4109 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4110 return ExprError();
4111 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004112 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4113 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4114 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4115 }
4116 else
4117 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4118 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004119
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004120 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4121 // then handle it as such.
4122 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004123 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4124 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4125 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4126
4127 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4128 // braces instead of the original commas.
4129 Op.release();
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004130 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4131 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004132 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4133 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004134 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004135 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004136 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004137 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4138 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004139 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004140 }
4141}
4142
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004143Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004144 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004145 MultiExprArg Val,
4146 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004147 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4148 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004149 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4150 Expr *expr;
4151 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4152 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4153 else
4154 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004155 return Owned(expr);
4156}
4157
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004158/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4159/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004160/// C99 6.5.15
4161QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4162 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004163 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4164 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4165 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4166
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004167 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4168 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4169 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4170 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4171 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4172 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004173
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004174 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004175 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4176 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4177 << CondTy;
4178 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004179 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004180
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004181 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004182 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4183 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004184
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004185 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4186 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004187 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4188 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4189 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004190 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004191
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004192 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4193 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004194 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4195 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004196 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004197 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004198 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004199 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004200 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004201 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004202
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004203 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004204 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004205 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4206 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4207 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4208 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4209 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4210 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4211 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004212 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4213 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004214 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004215 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004216 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4217 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004218 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004219 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004220 // promote the null to a pointer.
4221 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004222 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004223 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004224 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004225 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004226 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004227 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004228 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004229
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004230 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4231 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4232 QuestionLoc);
4233 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4234 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004235
4236
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004237 // Handle block pointer types.
4238 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4239 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4240 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4241 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004242 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4243 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004244 return destType;
4245 }
4246 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004247 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004248 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004249 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004250 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4251 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4252 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004253 return LHSTy;
4254 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004255 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004256 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4257 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004258
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004259 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4260 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004261 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004262 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004263 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4264 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4265 // to get a consistent AST.
4266 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004267 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4268 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004269 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004270 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004271 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004272 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4273 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004274 return LHSTy;
4275 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004276
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004277 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4278 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4279 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004280 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4281 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004282
4283 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4284 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4285 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004286 QualType destPointee
4287 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004288 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004289 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4290 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4291 // Promote to void*.
4292 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004293 return destType;
4294 }
4295 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004296 QualType destPointee
4297 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004298 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004299 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004300 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004301 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004302 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004303 return destType;
4304 }
4305
4306 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4307 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4308 return LHSTy;
4309 }
4310 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4311 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4312 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4313 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4314 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4315 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4316 // to get a consistent AST.
4317 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004318 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4319 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004320 return incompatTy;
4321 }
4322 // The pointer types are compatible.
4323 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4324 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4325 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4326 // type.
4327 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4328 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004329 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4330 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004331 return LHSTy;
4332 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004333
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004334 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4335 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4336 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4337 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004338 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004339 return RHSTy;
4340 }
4341 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4342 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4343 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004344 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004345 return LHSTy;
4346 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004347
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004348 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004349 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4350 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004351 return QualType();
4352}
4353
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004354/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4355/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4356QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4357 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4358 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4359 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004360
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004361 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4362 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4363 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4364 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4365 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4366 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4367 return LHSTy;
4368 }
4369 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4370 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4371 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4372 return RHSTy;
4373 }
4374 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4375 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4376 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4377 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4378 return LHSTy;
4379 }
4380 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4381 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4382 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4383 return RHSTy;
4384 }
4385 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4386 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4387 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4388 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4389 return LHSTy;
4390 }
4391 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4392 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4393 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4394 return RHSTy;
4395 }
4396 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4397 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004398
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004399 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4400 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4401 return LHSTy;
4402 }
4403 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4404 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4405 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004406
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004407 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4408 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4409 // type. This allows
4410 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4411 // where B is a subclass of A.
4412 //
4413 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4414 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4415 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4416 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004417
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004418 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4419 // It could return the composite type.
4420 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4421 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4422 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4423 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4424 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4425 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4426 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4427 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4428 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4429 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4430 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4431 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4432 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4433 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004434 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004435 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4436 ;
4437 else {
4438 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4439 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4440 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4441 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4442 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4443 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4444 return incompatTy;
4445 }
4446 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4447 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4448 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4449 return compositeType;
4450 }
4451 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4452 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4453 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4454 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4455 QualType destPointee
4456 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4457 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4458 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4459 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4460 // Promote to void*.
4461 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4462 return destType;
4463 }
4464 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4465 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4466 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4467 QualType destPointee
4468 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4469 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4470 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4471 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4472 // Promote to void*.
4473 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4474 return destType;
4475 }
4476 return QualType();
4477}
4478
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004479/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004480/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004481Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4482 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4483 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4484 ExprArg RHS) {
4485 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4486 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004487
4488 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4489 // was the condition.
4490 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4491 if (isLHSNull)
4492 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004493
4494 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattner26824902007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004495 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004496 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004497 return ExprError();
4498
4499 Cond.release();
4500 LHS.release();
4501 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004502 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004503 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004504 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004505}
4506
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004507// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004508// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004509// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4510// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4511// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004512Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004513Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4514 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004515
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004516 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4517 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4518 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4519 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4520 return Compatible;
4521 }
4522
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004523 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004524 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4525 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004526
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004527 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004528 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4529 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004530
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004531 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004532
4533 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4534 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4535 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004536 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004537 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004538 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004539
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004540 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4541 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004542 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004543 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004544 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004545 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004546
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004547 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004548 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4549 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004550 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004551
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004552 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004553 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004554 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004555
4556 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004557 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4558 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004559 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004560 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004561 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004562 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4563 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4564 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4565 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4566 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4567 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004568 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004569 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004570 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004571 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004572
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004573 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004574 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004575 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004576 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004577
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004578 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4579 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4580 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4581 // warning can be disabled.
4582 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4583 return ConvTy;
4584 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4585 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004586
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004587 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4588 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4589 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4590 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4591 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4592 do {
4593 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4594 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004595
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004596 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4597 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4598 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004599
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004600 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004601 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004602 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004603
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004604 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004605 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004606 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004607 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004608}
4609
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004610/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4611/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4612/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4613// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004614Sema::AssignConvertType
4615Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004616 QualType rhsType) {
4617 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004618
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004619 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004620 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4621 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004622
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004623 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4624 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4625 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004626
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004627 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004628
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004629 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004630 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004631 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004632
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004633 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4634 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4635 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4636 }
4637 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004638 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004639 return ConvTy;
4640}
4641
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004642/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4643/// for assignment compatibility.
4644Sema::AssignConvertType
4645Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004646 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4647 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004648 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4649 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004650 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004651 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004652 }
4653 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4654 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004655 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4656 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004657 return IncompatiblePointer;
4658 return Compatible;
4659 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004660 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004661 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004662 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004663 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4664 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4665 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4666 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4667 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4668 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004669
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004670 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4671 return Compatible;
4672 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4673 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004674 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004675}
4676
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004677/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4678/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004679/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4680///
4681/// int a, *pint;
4682/// short *pshort;
4683/// struct foo *pfoo;
4684///
4685/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4686/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4687/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4688/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4689///
4690/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004691/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004692///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004693Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004694Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004695 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4696 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004697 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4698 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004699
4700 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004701 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004702
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004703 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4704 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4705 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4706 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4707 return Compatible;
4708 }
4709
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004710 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4711 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4712 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4713 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4714 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4715 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4716 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004717 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004718 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004719 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004720 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004721 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004722 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4723 // to the same ExtVector type.
4724 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4725 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4726 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004727 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004728 return Compatible;
4729 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004730
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004731 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004732 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4733 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4734 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4735 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4736 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4737 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004738 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004739
4740 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4741 // vector type and vice versa
4742 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4743 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004744 }
4745 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004746 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004747
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004748 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4749 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004750 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004751
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004752 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004753 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004754 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004755
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004756 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004757 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004758
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004759 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004760 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004761 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4762 return Compatible;
4763 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004764 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004765 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4766 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004767 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004768
4769 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004770 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004771 return Compatible;
4772 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004773 return Incompatible;
4774 }
4775
4776 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4777 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004778 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004779
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004780 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004781 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004782 return Compatible;
4783
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004784 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4785 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004786
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004787 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004788 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004789 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004790 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004791 return Incompatible;
4792 }
4793
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004794 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4795 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4796 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004797
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004798 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004799 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004800 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4801 return Compatible;
4802 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004803 }
4804 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004805 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004806 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004807 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004808 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4809 return Compatible;
4810 }
4811 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4812 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4813 return Compatible;
4814 return Incompatible;
4815 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004816 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004817 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004818 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4819 return Compatible;
4820
4821 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004822 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004823
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004824 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004825 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004826
4827 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004828 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004829 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004830 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004831 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004832 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4833 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4834 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4835 return Compatible;
4836
4837 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4838 return PointerToInt;
4839
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004840 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004841 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004842 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4843 return Compatible;
4844 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004845 }
4846 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004847 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004848 return Compatible;
4849 return Incompatible;
4850 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004851
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004852 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004853 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004854 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004855 }
4856 return Incompatible;
4857}
4858
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004859/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4860/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004861static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004862 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4863 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4864 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004865 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004866 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004867 SourceLocation());
4868 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4869 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4870
4871 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4872 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004873 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004874 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004875 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004876}
4877
4878Sema::AssignConvertType
4879Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4880 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4881
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004882 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004883 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4884 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004885 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004886 return Incompatible;
4887
4888 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4889 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4890 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4891 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004892 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4893 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004894 it != itend; ++it) {
4895 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4896 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4897 // 1) void pointer
4898 // 2) null pointer constant
4899 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004900 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004901 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004902 InitField = *it;
4903 break;
4904 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004905
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004906 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004907 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004908 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004909 InitField = *it;
4910 break;
4911 }
4912 }
4913
4914 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4915 == Compatible) {
4916 InitField = *it;
4917 break;
4918 }
4919 }
4920
4921 if (!InitField)
4922 return Incompatible;
4923
4924 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4925 return Compatible;
4926}
4927
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004928Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004929Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004930 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4931 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4932 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4933 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4934 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004935 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004936 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004937 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004938 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004939 }
4940
4941 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4942 // structures.
4943 }
4944
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004945 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4946 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004947 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4948 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004949 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004950 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004951 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004952 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004953 return Compatible;
4954 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004955
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004956 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004957 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004958 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00004959 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004960 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004961 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004962 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004963 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004964
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004965 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4966 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004967
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004968 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4969 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004970 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4971 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4972 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4973 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004974 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004975 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004976 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004977 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004978}
4979
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004980QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004981 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004982 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004983 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004984 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004985}
4986
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004987QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004988 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004989 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004990 QualType lhsType =
4991 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4992 QualType rhsType =
4993 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004994
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004995 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004996 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004997 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004998
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004999 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5000 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005001 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
5002 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005003 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5004 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005005 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005006 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005007 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5008 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5009 return lhsType;
5010 }
5011
5012 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5013 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005014 }
5015 }
5016 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005017
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005018 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5019 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5020 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
5021 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5022 return rhsType;
5023 }
5024
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005025 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5026 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5027 bool swapped = false;
5028 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5029 swapped = true;
5030 std::swap(rex, lex);
5031 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5032 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005033
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005034 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005035 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005036 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005037 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005038 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005039 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005040 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5041 return lhsType;
5042 }
5043 }
5044 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5045 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5046 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005047 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005048 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5049 return lhsType;
5050 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005051 }
5052 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005053
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005054 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005055 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005056 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005057 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005058 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005059}
5060
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005061QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5062 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005063 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005064 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005065
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005066 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005067
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005068 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5069 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5070 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005071
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005072 // Check for division by zero.
5073 if (isDiv &&
5074 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005075 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005076 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005077
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005078 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005079}
5080
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005081QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005082 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005083 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005084 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5085 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005086 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5087 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5088 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005089
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005090 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005091
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005092 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5093 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005094
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005095 // Check for remainder by zero.
5096 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005097 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5098 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005099
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005100 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005101}
5102
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005103QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005104 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005105 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5106 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5107 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5108 return compType;
5109 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005110
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005111 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005112
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005113 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005114 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5115 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5116 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005117 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005118 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005119
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005120 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5121 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005122 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005123 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5124
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005125 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005126
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005127 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005128 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005129
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005130 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5131 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005132 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5133 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005134 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005135 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005136 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005137
5138 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5139 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5140 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005141 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005142 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5143 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5144 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5145 return QualType();
5146 }
5147
5148 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5149 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5150 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005151 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005152 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005153 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005154 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005155 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5156 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005157 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5158 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005159 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005160 return QualType();
5161 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005162 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005163 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005164 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5165 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5166 return QualType();
5167 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005168
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005169 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005170 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5171 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5172 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5173 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5174 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005175 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005176 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5177 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005178 return PExp->getType();
5179 }
5180 }
5181
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005182 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005183}
5184
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005185// C99 6.5.6
5186QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005187 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5188 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5189 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5190 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5191 return compType;
5192 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005193
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005194 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005195
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005196 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005197
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005198 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005199 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5200 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005201 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005202 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005203 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005204
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005205 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005206 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005207 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005208
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005209 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005210
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005211 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5212 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5213 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5214 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5215 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5216 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5217 return QualType();
5218 }
5219
5220 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5221 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5222 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5223 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5224 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005225 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005226 return QualType();
5227 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005228
5229 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5230 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5231 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005232 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005233 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005234 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005235 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005236 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005237
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005238 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005239 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005240 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5241 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5242 return QualType();
5243 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005244
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005245 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005246 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5247 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5248 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5249 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5250 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5251 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005252 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005253 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5254
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005255 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005256 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005257 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005258
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005259 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005260 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005261 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005262
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005263 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5264 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5265 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5266 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5267 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5268 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5269 return QualType();
5270 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005271
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005272 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5273 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5274 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5275 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005276 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005277 return QualType();
5278 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005279
5280 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5281 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5282 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5283 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5284 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005285 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5286 << rex->getSourceRange()
5287 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005288 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005289
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005290 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5291 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5292 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5293 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5294 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5295 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5296 return QualType();
5297 }
5298 } else {
5299 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5300 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5301 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5302 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5303 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5304 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5305 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5306 return QualType();
5307 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005308 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005309
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005310 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5311 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5312 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5313 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5314 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005315 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005316 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005317
5318 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005319 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5320 }
5321 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005322
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005323 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005324}
5325
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005326// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005327QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005328 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005329 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005330 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5331 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005332 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005333
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005334 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5335 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5336 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5337
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005338 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5339 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005340 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5341 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5342 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5343 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5344 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005345 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005346 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005347 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005348
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005349 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005350
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005351 // Sanity-check shift operands
5352 llvm::APSInt Right;
5353 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005354 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5355 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005356 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005357 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5358 else {
5359 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5360 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5361 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5362 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5363 }
5364 }
5365
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005366 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005367 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005368}
5369
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005370static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5371 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5372 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5373 return true;
5374 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5375 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5376 }
5377 return false;
5378}
5379
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005380// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005381QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005382 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5383 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5384
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005385 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005386 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005387 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005388
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005389 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5390 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005391
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005392 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5393 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005394 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5395 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5396 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005397 //
5398 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5399 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5400 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5401 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5402 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5403 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005404 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5405 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005406 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005407 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005408 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005409 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005410 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5411 << 0 // self-
5412 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5413 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5414 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5415 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5416 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5417 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5418 // what is it always going to eval to?
5419 char always_evals_to;
5420 switch(Opc) {
5421 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5422 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5423 break;
5424 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5425 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5426 break;
5427 default:
5428 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5429 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5430 break;
5431 }
5432 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5433 << 1 // array
5434 << always_evals_to);
5435 }
5436 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005437 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005438
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005439 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5440 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5441 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5442 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005443
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005444 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5445 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005446 Expr *literalString = 0;
5447 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005448 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005449 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005450 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005451 literalString = lex;
5452 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005453 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5454 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005455 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005456 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005457 literalString = rex;
5458 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5459 }
5460
5461 if (literalString) {
5462 std::string resultComparison;
5463 switch (Opc) {
5464 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5465 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5466 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5467 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5468 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5469 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5470 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5471 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005472
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005473 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5474 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5475 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005476 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005477 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005478 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005479
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005480 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5481 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5482 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5483 else {
5484 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5485 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5486 }
5487
5488 lType = lex->getType();
5489 rType = rex->getType();
5490
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005491 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005492 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005493
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005494 if (isRelational) {
5495 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005496 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005497 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005498 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005499 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005500 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005501
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005502 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005503 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005504 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005505
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005506 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005507 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005508 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005509 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005510
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005511 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5512 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005513 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005514 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005515 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005516 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005517 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005518
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005519 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005520 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5521 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005522 if (!isRelational &&
5523 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5524 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5525 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005526 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5527 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005528 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5529 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005530 Diag(Loc,
5531 isSFINAEContext()?
5532 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5533 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005534 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005535
5536 if (isSFINAEContext())
5537 return QualType();
5538
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005539 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5540 return ResultTy;
5541 }
5542 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005543 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5544 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5545 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5546 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5547 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5548 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005549 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005550 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005551 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005552 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005553 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005554 if (T.isNull()) {
5555 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5556 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5557 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005558 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005559 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005560 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005561 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005562 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005563 }
5564
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005565 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5566 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005567 return ResultTy;
5568 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005569 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5570 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5571 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5572 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5573 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5574 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5575 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5576 }
5577 } else if (!isRelational &&
5578 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5579 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5580 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5581 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5582 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5583 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5584 }
5585 } else {
5586 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005587 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005588 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005589 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005590 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005591 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005592 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005593 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005594
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005595 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005596 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005597 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005598 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005599 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5600 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005601 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005602 return ResultTy;
5603 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005604 if (LHSIsNull &&
5605 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5606 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005607 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005608 return ResultTy;
5609 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005610
5611 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005612 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005613 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5614 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005615 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5616 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5617 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5618 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5619 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5620 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5621 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5622 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005623 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005624 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005625 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005626 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005627 if (T.isNull()) {
5628 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005629 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005630 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005631 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005632 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005633 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005634 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005635 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005636 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005637
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005638 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5639 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005640 return ResultTy;
5641 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005642
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005643 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005644 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5645 return ResultTy;
5646 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005647
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005648 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005649 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005650 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5651 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005652
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005653 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005654 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005655 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005656 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005657 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005658 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005659 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005660 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005661 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005662 if (!isRelational
5663 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5664 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005665 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005666 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005667 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005668 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005669 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5670 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5671 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005672 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005673 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005674 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005675 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005676
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005677 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005678 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005679 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5680 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005681 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005682 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005683 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005684 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005685
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005686 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5687 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005688 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005689 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005690 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005691 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005692 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005693 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005694 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005695 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005696 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5697 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005698 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005699 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005700 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005701 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005702 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5703 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005704 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005705 bool isError = false;
5706 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5707 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5708 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005709 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005710 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005711 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005712 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5713 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5714 isError = true;
5715 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005716 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005717
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005718 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005719 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005720 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005721 if (isError)
5722 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005723 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005724
5725 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5726 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005727 else
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005728 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005729 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005730 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005731
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005732 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005733 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5734 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005735 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005736 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005737 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005738 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5739 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005740 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005741 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005742 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005743 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005744}
5745
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005746/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005747/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005748/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5749/// types.
5750QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005751 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005752 bool isRelational) {
5753 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5754 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005755 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005756 if (vType.isNull())
5757 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005758
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005759 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5760 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005761
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005762 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5763 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5764 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005765 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005766 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5767 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5768 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005769 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5770 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5771 << 0 // self-
5772 << 2 // "a constant"
5773 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005774 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005775
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005776 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005777 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5778 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005779 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005780 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005781
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005782 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5783 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5784 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005785 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005786 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005787
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005788 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005789 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005790 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005791 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005792 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005793 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5794
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005795 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005796 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005797 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5798}
5799
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005800inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005801 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005802 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5803 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5804 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5805 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5806
5807 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5808 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005809
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005810 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005811
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005812 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005813 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005814 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005815}
5816
5817inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005818 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5819
5820 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5821 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5822 // is a constant.
5823 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005824 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005825 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005826 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5827 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5828 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5829 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5830 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5831 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5832 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5833 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5834 << rex->getSourceRange()
5835 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5836 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&" : "|");
5837 }
5838 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005839
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005840 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5841 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5842 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005843
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005844 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5845 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005846
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005847 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005848 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005849
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005850 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5851 // non-overloadable operands.
5852
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005853 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5854 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005855 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5856 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5857 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005858 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005859
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005860 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5861 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5862 // The result is a bool.
5863 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005864}
5865
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005866/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5867/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5868/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5869///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005870static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005871 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5872 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5873 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5874 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005875 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005876 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5877 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5878 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5879 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005880 }
5881 }
5882 return false;
5883}
5884
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005885/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5886/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5887static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005888 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005889 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005890 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005891 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5892 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005893 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5894 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005895
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005896 unsigned Diag = 0;
5897 bool NeedType = false;
5898 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005899 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005900 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005901 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5902 NeedType = true;
5903 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005904 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005905 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5906 NeedType = true;
5907 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005908 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005909 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5910 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005911 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5912 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005913 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005914 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5915 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005916 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5917 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005918 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5919 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005920 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005921 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005922 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005923 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005924 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5925 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005926 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005927 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5928 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005929 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5930 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5931 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005932 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5933 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5934 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005935 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5936 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5937 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005938 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005939
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005940 SourceRange Assign;
5941 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5942 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005943 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005944 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005945 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005946 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005947 return true;
5948}
5949
5950
5951
5952// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005953QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5954 SourceLocation Loc,
5955 QualType CompoundType) {
5956 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5957 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005958 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005959
5960 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5961 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005962 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005963 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005964 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005965 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005966 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5967 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5968 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5969 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5970 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5971 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5972 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5973 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5974 }
5975 }
5976
5977 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005978 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5979 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5980 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005981 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005982 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005983 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005984 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005985
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005986 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5987 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5988 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005989 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005990 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5991 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5992 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5993 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5994 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005995 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005996 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005997 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5998 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5999 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006000 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6001 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006002 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
6003 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
6004 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006005 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006006 }
6007 } else {
6008 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006009 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006010 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006011
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006012 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006013 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006014 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006015
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006016
6017 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6018 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6019 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6020 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6021 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6022 // check.
6023 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
6024 if (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref &&
6025 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6026 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6027 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6028 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6029 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6030 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6031 }
6032
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006033 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6034 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006035 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006036 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6037 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006038 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006039 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006040 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006041}
6042
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006043// C99 6.5.17
6044QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006045 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6046
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006047 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006048 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6049 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6050 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006051
6052 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6053 // incomplete in C++).
6054
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006055 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006056}
6057
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006058/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6059/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006060QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006061 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006062 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6063 return Context.DependentTy;
6064
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006065 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6066 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006067
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006068 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6069 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6070 if (!isInc) {
6071 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6072 return QualType();
6073 }
6074 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6075 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6076 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006077 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006078 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6079 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006080
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006081 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006082 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006083 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6084 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6085 << Op->getSourceRange();
6086 return QualType();
6087 }
6088
6089 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006090 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006091 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006092 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6093 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6094 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6095 return QualType();
6096 }
6097
6098 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006099 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006100 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006101 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006102 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006103 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006104 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006105 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006106 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006107 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6108 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6109 return QualType();
6110 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006111 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006112 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6113 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006114 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006115 } else {
6116 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006117 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006118 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006119 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006120 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006121 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006122 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006123 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006124 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6125 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6126 // operand.
6127 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6128 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006129}
6130
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006131/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006132/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006133/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6134/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6135/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6136/// - &(x) => x
6137/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6138/// - &s.xx => s
6139/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6140/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6141/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6142/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006143static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006144 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006145 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006146 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006147 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006148 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6149 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6150 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006151 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006152 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006153 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006154 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006155 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006156 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6157 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006158 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6159 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6160 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6161 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6162 }
6163 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006164 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006165 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6166 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006167
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006168 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006169 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6170 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6171 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6172 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6173 default:
6174 return 0;
6175 }
6176 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006177 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006178 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006179 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006180 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6181 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006182 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006183 default:
6184 return 0;
6185 }
6186}
6187
6188/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006189/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006190/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006191/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006192/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006193/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006194/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006195QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006196 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6197 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6198
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006199 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6200 return Context.DependentTy;
6201
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006202 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6203 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6204 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6205 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6206 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6207 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6208 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6209 }
6210 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6211 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6212 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006213 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006214 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006215
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006216 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6217 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6218 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6219 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6220 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6221 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6222 // branch of the if, below.
6223 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6224 << dcl;
6225 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6226
6227 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6228 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6229 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6230 .getTypePtr());
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006231 }
6232
6233 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006234 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6235 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6236 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6237 if (isSFINAEContext())
6238 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerc721ae82010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006239 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op))
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006240 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Chris Lattnerc721ae82010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006241 else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006242 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006243 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006244 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006245 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006246 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6247 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006248 return QualType();
6249 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006250 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006251 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6252 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6253 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006254 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006255 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006256 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006257 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006258 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006259 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006260 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6261 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6262 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6263 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6264 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006265 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6266 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006267 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6268 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006269 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6270 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006271 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006272 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006273 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6274 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
6275 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006276 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6277 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006278 return QualType();
6279 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006280 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006281 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006282 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006283 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006284 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6285 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006286 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006287 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006288 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6289 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006290 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006291 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6292 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6293 return QualType();
6294 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006295
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006296 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6297 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006298 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006299 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006300 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes6fea8d22008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006301 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006302 // As above.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006303 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6304 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006305 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6306 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6307 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006308 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006309 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006310
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006311 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6312 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6313 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6314 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6315 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6316 }
6317
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006318 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006319 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6320 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006321 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6322}
6323
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006324/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006325QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006326 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6327 return Context.DependentTy;
6328
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006329 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006330 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6331 QualType Result;
6332
6333 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6334 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6335 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6336 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6337 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6338 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6339 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6340 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6341 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006342
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006343 if (Result.isNull()) {
6344 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6345 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6346 return QualType();
6347 }
6348
6349 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006350}
6351
6352static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6353 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6354 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6355 switch (Kind) {
6356 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006357 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6358 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006359 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6360 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6361 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6362 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6363 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6364 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6365 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6366 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6367 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6368 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6369 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6370 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6371 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6372 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6373 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6374 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6375 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6376 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6377 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6378 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6379 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6380 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6381 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6382 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6383 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6384 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6385 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6386 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6387 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6388 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6389 }
6390 return Opc;
6391}
6392
6393static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6394 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6395 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6396 switch (Kind) {
6397 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6398 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6399 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6400 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6401 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6402 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6403 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6404 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6405 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006406 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6407 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
6408 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
6409 }
6410 return Opc;
6411}
6412
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006413/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6414/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6415/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006416Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6417 unsigned Op,
6418 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006419 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006420 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006421 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6422 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6423 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006424
6425 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006426 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6427 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6428 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006429 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6430 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6431 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6432 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6433 break;
6434 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006435 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006436 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6437 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006438 break;
6439 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6440 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6441 break;
6442 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6443 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6444 break;
6445 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6446 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6447 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006448 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006449 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6450 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6451 break;
6452 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6453 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6454 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6455 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006456 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006457 break;
6458 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6459 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006460 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006461 break;
6462 case BinaryOperator::And:
6463 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6464 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6465 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6466 break;
6467 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6468 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006469 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006470 break;
6471 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6472 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006473 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6474 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006475 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6476 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6477 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006478 break;
6479 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006480 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6481 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6482 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6483 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006484 break;
6485 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006486 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6487 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6488 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006489 break;
6490 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006491 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6492 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6493 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006494 break;
6495 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6496 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006497 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6498 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6499 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6500 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006501 break;
6502 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6503 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6504 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006505 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6506 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6507 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6508 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006509 break;
6510 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6511 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6512 break;
6513 }
6514 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006515 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006516 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006517 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6518 else
6519 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006520 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6521 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006522}
6523
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006524/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6525/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006526static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6527 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006528 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6529 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6530 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006531 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006532 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6533
6534 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6535 return;
6536
6537 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6538 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6539 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006540 return;
6541 }
6542
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006543 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6544 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006545 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006546
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006547 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006548 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006549
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006550 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6551 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6552 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6553 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006554 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006555 return;
6556 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006557
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006558 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006559 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6560 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006561}
6562
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006563/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6564/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6565/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6566/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006567static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6568 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006569 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6570 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6571 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6572 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006573 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006574 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006575 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6576
6577 // Subs are not binary operators.
6578 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6579 return;
6580
6581 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6582 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006583 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6584 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006585 return;
6586
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006587 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006588 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006589 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006590 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6591 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006592 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006593 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006594 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6595 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6596 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6597 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006598 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006599 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006600 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006601 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6602 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006603 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006604 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006605 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6606 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6607 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6608 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006609}
6610
6611/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6612/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6613/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6614static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6615 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006616 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006617 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6618}
6619
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006620// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006621Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6622 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6623 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006624 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006625 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006626
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006627 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6628 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006629
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006630 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6631 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6632
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006633 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6634}
6635
6636Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6637 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6638 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006639 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006640 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006641 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6642 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6643 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6644 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6645 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006646 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006647 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006648 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6649 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6650 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006651
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006652 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6653 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006654 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006655 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006656
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006657 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006658 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006659}
6660
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006661Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006662 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006663 ExprArg InputArg) {
6664 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006665
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006666 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006667 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006668 QualType resultType;
6669 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006670 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6671 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6672 break;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006673
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006674 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6675 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006676 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6677 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006678 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006679 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006680 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6681 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6682 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006683 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006684 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006685 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6686 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006687 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006688 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006689 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6690 break;
6691 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6692 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006693 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6694 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006695 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6696 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006697 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6698 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006699 break;
6700 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6701 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6702 break;
6703 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6704 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6705 resultType->isPointerType())
6706 break;
6707
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006708 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6709 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006710 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006711 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6712 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006713 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6714 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006715 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6716 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6717 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006718 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006719 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006720 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006721 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6722 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006723 break;
6724 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
6725 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006726 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006727 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006728 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6729 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006730 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006731 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6732 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006733 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006734 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6735 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006736 break;
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006737 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006738 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006739 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006740 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006741 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006742 resultType = Input->getType();
6743 break;
6744 }
6745 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006746 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006747
6748 InputArg.release();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006749 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006750}
6751
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006752Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6753 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6754 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006755 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006756 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6757 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006758 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6759 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6760 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6761 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006762 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006763 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006764 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6765 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6766 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006767
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006768 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6769 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006770
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006771 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6772}
6773
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006774// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6775Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6776 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6777 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6778}
6779
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006780/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006781Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6782 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6783 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006784 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattnerea29a3a2009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006785 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006786
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006787 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6788 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006789 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006790 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006791
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006792 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006793 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6794 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006795}
6796
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006797Sema::OwningExprResult
6798Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6799 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6800 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006801 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6802 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6803
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006804 bool isFileScope
6805 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006806 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006807 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006808
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006809 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6810 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6811 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006812
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006813 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6814 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6815 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006816
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006817 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6818 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6819 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6820 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6821 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006822
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006823 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006824 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006825 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006826
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006827 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6828 // expressions are not lvalues.
6829
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006830 substmt.release();
6831 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006832}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006833
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006834Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6835 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006836 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6837 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006838 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6839 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006840 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006841 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006842
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006843 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6844 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6845 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006846 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006847 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6848 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6849
6850 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6851 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6852 if (!Dependent
6853 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6854 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6855 << TypeRange))
6856 return ExprError();
6857
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006858 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6859 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006860 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6861 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006862 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006863 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6864 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006865
6866 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6867 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6868 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6869 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6870 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6871 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6872 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6873 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6874 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6875 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6876 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6877 if(!AT)
6878 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6879 << CurrentType);
6880 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6881 } else
6882 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6883
6884 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6885 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6886 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6887 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6888 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6889 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6890 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6891 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6892
6893 // Record this array index.
6894 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6895 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6896 continue;
6897 }
6898
6899 // Offset of a field.
6900 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6901 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6902 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6903 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6904 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6905 continue;
6906 }
6907
6908 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6909 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6910 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6911 return ExprError();
6912
6913 // Look for the designated field.
6914 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6915 if (!RC)
6916 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6917 << CurrentType);
6918 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6919
6920 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6921 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6922 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6923 // (clause 9).
6924 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6925 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6926 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6927 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6928 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6929 << CurrentType))
6930 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6931 }
6932
6933 // Look for the field.
6934 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6935 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6936 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6937 if (!MemberDecl)
6938 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6939 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6940 OC.LocEnd));
6941
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006942 // C99 7.17p3:
6943 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6944 //
6945 // We diagnose this as an error.
6946 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6947 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6948 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6949 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6950 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6951 return ExprError();
6952 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006953
6954 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
6955 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
6956 if (AnonStructUnion) {
6957 do {
6958 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
6959 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
6960 }
6961
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006962 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6963 // the base class indirections.
6964 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6965 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006966 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006967 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6968 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6969 B != BEnd; ++B)
6970 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6971 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006972
6973 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006974 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6975 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6976 unsigned n = Path.size();
6977 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6978 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6979 } else {
6980 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6981 }
6982 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6983 }
6984
6985 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6986 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6987 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6988}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006989
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006990Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6991 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6992 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6993 TypeTy *argty,
6994 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6995 unsigned NumComponents,
6996 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6997
6998 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6999 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7000 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7001 return ExprError();
7002
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007003 if (!ArgTInfo)
7004 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7005
7006 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7007 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007008}
7009
7010
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007011Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7012 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
7013 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007014 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
7015 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
7016 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007017
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007018 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007019
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007020 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7021 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7022 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7023 return ExprError();
7024 }
7025
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007026 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
7027 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007028}
7029
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007030Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7031 ExprArg cond,
7032 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
7033 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7034 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
7035 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
7036 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007037
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007038 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7039
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007040 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007041 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007042 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007043 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007044 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007045 } else {
7046 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7047 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7048 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7049 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007050 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7051 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7052 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007053
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007054 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7055 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007056 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7057 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007058 }
7059
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007060 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7061 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007062 resType, RPLoc,
7063 resType->isDependentType(),
7064 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007065}
7066
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007067//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7068// Clang Extensions.
7069//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7070
7071/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007072void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007073 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7074 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7075 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007076 if (BlockScope)
7077 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7078 else
7079 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007080}
7081
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007082void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007083 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007084 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007085
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007086 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007087 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007088 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007089
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007090 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007091 QualType RetTy;
7092 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007093 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007094 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007095 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007096 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7097 } else {
7098 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007099 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007100 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007101
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007102 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007103
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007104 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7105 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7106 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007107 return;
7108 }
7109
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007110 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7111 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7112 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7113 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7114 return;
7115 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007116
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007117 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007118 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7119 // ^ * { ... }
7120 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007121 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7122 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007123
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007124 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007125 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007126 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7127 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7128 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7129 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007130 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7131 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7132 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7133 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7134 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007135 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007136 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007137
7138 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7139 // ^ fntype { ... }
7140 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7141 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7142 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7143 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7144 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7145 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7146 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007147 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007148 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007149 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007150
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007151 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7152 if (!Params.empty())
7153 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007154
7155 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007156 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007157
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007158 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007159 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7160 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7161 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7162 }
7163
7164 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7165 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007166 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007167 return;
7168
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007169 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7170 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7171
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007172 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007173 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7174 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7175
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007176 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007177 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7178 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7179 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7180
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007181 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007182 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007183 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007184}
7185
7186/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7187/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7188void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007189 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007190 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007191 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007192 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007193}
7194
7195/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7196/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007197Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7198 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007199 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7200 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7201 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007202
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007203 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007204
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007205 PopDeclContext();
7206
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007207 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007208 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7209 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007210
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007211 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007212 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007213
7214 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7215 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7216 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7217
7218 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7219 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7220
7221 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7222 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7223 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7224 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7225
7226 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7227 // preserve its sugar structure.
7228 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7229 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7230 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7231
7232 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7233 } else {
7234 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7235 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7236 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7237 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7238 FPT->isVariadic(),
7239 /*quals*/ 0,
7240 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7241 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7242 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7243 FPT->exception_begin(),
7244 Ext);
7245 }
7246
7247 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7248 } else {
7249 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7250 false, false, 0, 0,
7251 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7252 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007253
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007254 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007255 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7256 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007257 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007258
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007259 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007260 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007261 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007262
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007263 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007264
7265 bool Good = true;
7266 // Check goto/label use.
7267 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7268 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7269 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7270
7271 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7272 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7273 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7274 continue;
7275
7276 // Emit error.
7277 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7278 Good = false;
7279 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007280 if (!Good) {
7281 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007282 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007283 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007284
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007285 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007286 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7287 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7288 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007289
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007290 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7291 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007292 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007293 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007294}
7295
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007296Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7297 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7298 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007299 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007300 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7301 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007302
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007303 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007304
7305 // Get the va_list type
7306 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007307 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7308 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7309 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7310 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007311 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007312 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7313 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7314 } else {
7315 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7316 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007317 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007318 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007319 return ExprError();
7320 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007321
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007322 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7323 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007324 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7325 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007326 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007327 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007328
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007329 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007330 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007331
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007332 expr.release();
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00007333 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E,
7334 T.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007335 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007336}
7337
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007338Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007339 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7340 // pointers on the target.
7341 QualType Ty;
7342 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7343 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7344 else
7345 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7346
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007347 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007348}
7349
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007350static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007351 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007352 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7353 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007354
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007355 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7356 if (!PT)
7357 return;
7358
7359 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7360 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7361 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7362 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7363 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7364 return;
7365 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007366
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007367 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7368 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7369 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7370 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007371
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007372 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007373}
7374
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007375bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7376 SourceLocation Loc,
7377 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007378 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7379 bool *Complained) {
7380 if (Complained)
7381 *Complained = false;
7382
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007383 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7384 bool isInvalid = false;
7385 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007386 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007387
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007388 switch (ConvTy) {
7389 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7390 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007391 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007392 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7393 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007394 case IntToPointer:
7395 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7396 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007397 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007398 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007399 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7400 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007401 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7402 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7403 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007404 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7405 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7406 break;
7407 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007408 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7409 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7410 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7411 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7412 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7413 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7414 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7415 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7416 // C++ semantics.
7417 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7418 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7419 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007420 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7421 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007422 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007423 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007424 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007425 case IntToBlockPointer:
7426 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7427 break;
7428 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007429 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007430 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007431 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007432 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007433 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7434 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7435 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007436 case IncompatibleVectors:
7437 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7438 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007439 case Incompatible:
7440 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7441 isInvalid = true;
7442 break;
7443 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007444
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007445 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7446 switch (Action) {
7447 case AA_Assigning:
7448 case AA_Initializing:
7449 // The destination type comes first.
7450 FirstType = DstType;
7451 SecondType = SrcType;
7452 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007453
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007454 case AA_Returning:
7455 case AA_Passing:
7456 case AA_Converting:
7457 case AA_Sending:
7458 case AA_Casting:
7459 // The source type comes first.
7460 FirstType = SrcType;
7461 SecondType = DstType;
7462 break;
7463 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007464
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007465 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007466 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007467 if (Complained)
7468 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007469 return isInvalid;
7470}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007471
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007472bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007473 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7474 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7475 if (Result)
7476 *Result = ICEResult;
7477 return false;
7478 }
7479
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007480 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7481
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007482 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007483 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7484 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7485
7486 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7487 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7488 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7489 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7490 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7491 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7492 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007493
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007494 return true;
7495 }
7496
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007497 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7498 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007499
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007500 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7501 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7502 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007503
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007504 if (Result)
7505 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7506 return false;
7507}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007508
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007509void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007510Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007511 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7512 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007513}
7514
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007515void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007516Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7517 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7518 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7519 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007520
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007521 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7522 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7523 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7524 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7525 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007526 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007527 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7528 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7529 I != IEnd; ++I)
7530 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7531 }
7532
7533 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7534 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7535 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7536 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7537 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7538 I != IEnd; ++I)
7539 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7540 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007541 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007542
7543 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7544 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7545 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7546 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007547 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007548 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7549 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7550 ExprTemporaries.end());
7551
7552 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7553 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007554}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007555
7556/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7557///
7558/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7559/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7560/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7561/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7562///
7563/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7564///
7565/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7566void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7567 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007568
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007569 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007570 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007571
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007572 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7573 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7574 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7575 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007576 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007577 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007578 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007579 return;
7580 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007581
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007582 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7583 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007584
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007585 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7586 // an instantiation.
7587 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7588 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007589
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007590 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007591 case Unevaluated:
7592 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7593 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007594
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007595 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7596 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7597 // "used"; handle this below.
7598 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007599
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007600 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7601 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7602 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7603 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007604 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007605 return;
7606 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007607
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007608 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007609 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007610 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007611 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007612 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007613 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007614 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007615 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007616 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007617 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7618 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007619
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007620 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007621 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007622 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007623 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007624 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7625 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007626 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7627 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7628 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007629 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007630 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007631 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7632 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007633 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007634 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007635 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007636 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007637 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007638 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7639 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7640 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7641 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7642 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007643 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007644 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007645 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007646 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007647 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7648 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7649 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007650 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007651 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007652 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7653 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007654
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007655 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7656 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7657 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7658 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7659 Loc));
7660 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007661 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007662 Loc));
7663 }
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007664 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007665
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007666 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007667 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007668
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007669 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007670 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007671
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007672 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007673 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007674 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007675 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7676 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7677 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7678 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7679 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7680 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7681 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7682 }
7683 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007684
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007685 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007686
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007687 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007688 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007689 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007690}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007691
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007692namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007693 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007694 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007695 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007696 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7697 Sema &S;
7698 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007699
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007700 public:
7701 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007702
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007703 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007704
7705 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7706 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007707 };
7708}
7709
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007710bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7711 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007712 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7713 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7714 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007715
7716 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007717}
7718
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007719bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007720 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7721 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7722 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007723 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7724 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007725 }
7726
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007727 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007728}
7729
7730void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7731 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007732 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007733}
7734
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007735/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7736/// of the program being compiled.
7737///
7738/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007739/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007740/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7741/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7742/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7743/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007744/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007745/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007746///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007747/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7748/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7749/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7750/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007751bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007752 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7753 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7754 case Unevaluated:
7755 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7756 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007757
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007758 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7759 Diag(Loc, PD);
7760 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007761
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007762 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7763 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7764 break;
7765 }
7766
7767 return false;
7768}
7769
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007770bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7771 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7772 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7773 return false;
7774
7775 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7776 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7777 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7778 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007779
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007780 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007781 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007782 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7783 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007784 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007785 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7786 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7787 return true;
7788
7789 return false;
7790}
7791
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007792// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7793// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7794void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7795 SourceLocation Loc;
7796
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007797 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7798
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007799 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7800 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7801 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7802 return;
7803
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007804 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7805 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7806 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7807 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7808
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007809 // self = [<foo> init...]
7810 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7811 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7812 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7813
7814 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7815 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7816 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7817 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7818 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007819
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007820 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7821 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7822 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7823 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7824 return;
7825
7826 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7827 } else {
7828 // Not an assignment.
7829 return;
7830 }
7831
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007832 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007833 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007834
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007835 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007836 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007837 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007838 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7839 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7840 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007841}
7842
7843bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7844 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7845
7846 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007847 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007848
7849 QualType T = E->getType();
7850
7851 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7852 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7853 return true;
7854 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7855 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7856 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7857 return true;
7858 }
7859 }
7860
7861 return false;
7862}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007863
7864Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7865 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007866 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7867 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007868 return ExprError();
7869
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007870 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007871 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007872
7873 return Owned(Sub);
7874}